flash Kinetis: new KVx family added
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2407 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2408
2409 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2410 recommended as its replacement.
2411
2412 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2413 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2416 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2417 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2418 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2419 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2423 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2424 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2425 is connected to the host.
2426 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2427 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2428 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2432 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2433 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2434 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2435 @itemize @minus
2436 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2437 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2438 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2439 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2440 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2441 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2442 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2443 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2444 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2445 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2446 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2447 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2448 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2449 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2450 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2451 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2453 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2454 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2455 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2456 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2457 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2458 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2459 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2460 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2461 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2462 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2463 @end itemize
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2467 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2468 default values are used.
2469 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2470 @example
2471 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2472 @end example
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2476 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2477 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2478 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2479 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2480 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2481 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2485 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2486 The default value is 1.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 For example, the interface config file for a
2490 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2491
2492 @example
2493 interface ft2232
2494 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2495 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2496 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2501 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2502 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2503 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2504 interface driver.
2505
2506 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2507 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2508 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2509
2510 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2511 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2512 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2513
2514 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2515 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2516 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2517 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2518 will be used for their customary purpose.
2519
2520 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2521 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2522 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2523 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2524
2525 @itemize @minus
2526 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2527 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2528 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2529 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2530 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2531 switching data and direction as necessary
2532 @end itemize
2533
2534 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2535 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2538 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2539 default values are used.
2540 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2541 @example
2542 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2543 @end example
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2547 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2548 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2549 during device selection.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2553 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2554 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2555 is connected to the host.
2556 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2557 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2558 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2562 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2563 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2564 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2565 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2566 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2570 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2571 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2575 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2576 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2577 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2578 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2579 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2580 and initially asserted reset signals.
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2584 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2585 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2586 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2587 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2588 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2589 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2590 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2591 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2592
2593 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2594 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2595 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2596 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2597 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2598 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2599
2600 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2601 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2602 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2603 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2604 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2605 are always driven by the FTDI.
2606
2607 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2608 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2609 @var{name}.
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2613 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2614 @itemize @minus
2615 @item @option{0}, drive low
2616 @item @option{1}, drive high
2617 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2618 @end itemize
2619 @end deffn
2620
2621 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2622 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2623
2624 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2625 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2626 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2627 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2628 @itemize @minus
2629 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2630 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2631 @end itemize
2632 @end deffn
2633
2634 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2635 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2636
2637 @end deffn
2638
2639 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2640 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2641 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2642 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2643
2644 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2645 processors which are being simulated.
2646
2647 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2648 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2649 sockets instead of TCP.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2653 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2654 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2655 @end deffn
2656
2657 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2658 something like:
2659
2660 @example
2661 interface remote_bitbang
2662 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2663 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2664 @end example
2665
2666 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2667 named mysocket:
2668
2669 @example
2670 interface remote_bitbang
2671 remote_bitbang_port 0
2672 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2673 @end example
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2677 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2678 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2679 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2680
2681 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2682 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2683 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2684 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2685 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2689 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2690 default values are used.
2691 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2692 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2693 @example
2694 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2695 @end example
2696 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2697 @example
2698 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2699 @end example
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2703 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2704 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2705 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2706 target board.
2707
2708 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2709 @example
2710 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2711 reset_config srst_only
2712 @end example
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2716 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2717 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2718 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2719 @end deffn
2720
2721 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2722 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2723 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2729 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2730 This has one driver-specific command:
2731
2732 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2733 Display either the address of the I/O port
2734 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2735 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2736 This is a write-once setting.
2737 @end deffn
2738 @end deffn
2739
2740 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2741 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2742 transports.
2743
2744 @quotation Compatibility Note
2745 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2746 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2747 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2748 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2749 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2750 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2751 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2752 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2753 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2754 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2755 @end quotation
2756
2757 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2758 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2759 states.
2760 @end deffn
2761 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2762 Display free device internal memory.
2763 @end deffn
2764 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2765 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2766 command version.
2767 @end deffn
2768 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2769 Display the device configuration.
2770 @end deffn
2771 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2772 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2773 power state.
2774 @end deffn
2775 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2776 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2777 @end deffn
2778 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2779 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2780 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2781 IP configuration.
2782 @end deffn
2783 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2784 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2785 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2786 @end deffn
2787 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2788 Reset the current configuration.
2789 @end deffn
2790 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2791 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2792 @end deffn
2793 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2794 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2795 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2796 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2797 instead.
2798
2799 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2802 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2803 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2804
2805 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @end deffn
2808
2809 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2810 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2811 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2812 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2813 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2814
2815 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2816 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2817 This is a write-once setting.
2818 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2819
2820 @itemize @minus
2821 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2822 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2823 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2824 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2825 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2826 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2827 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2828 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2829 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2830 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2831 some versions of
2832 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2833 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2834 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2835 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2836 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2837 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2838 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2839 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2840 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2841 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2842 @end itemize
2843 @end deffn
2844
2845 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2846 Display either the address of the I/O port
2847 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2848 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2849 This is a write-once setting.
2850
2851 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2852 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2853 you may encounter a problem.
2854 @end deffn
2855
2856 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2857 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2858 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2859 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2860 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2861 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2862
2863 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2864 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2865 @quotation Tip
2866 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2867 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2868 @example
2869 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2870 > adapter_khz 500
2871 @end example
2872 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2873 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2874 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2875 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2876 large set of samples.
2877 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2878 @example
2879 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2880 @end example
2881 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2882 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2883
2884 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2885 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2886 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2887 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2888 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2889 @end quotation
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2893 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2894 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2895 @end deffn
2896
2897 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2898 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2899
2900 @example
2901 interface parport
2902 parport_port 0x278
2903 parport_cable wiggler
2904 @end example
2905 @end deffn
2906
2907 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2908 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2909 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2910 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2911 @end deffn
2912 @end deffn
2913
2914 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2915 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2916 @end deffn
2917
2918 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2919 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2923 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2924
2925 @quotation Note
2926 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2927 which are not currently documented here.
2928 @end quotation
2929 @end deffn
2930
2931 @anchor{hla_interface}
2932 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2933 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2934 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2935 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2936
2937 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2938 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2939 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2940 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2941 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2942
2943 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2944 Currently Not Supported.
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2948 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2952 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2953 @end deffn
2954
2955 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2956 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2960 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2961 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2962 @end deffn
2963 @end deffn
2964
2965 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2966 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2970 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2971 @end deffn
2972
2973 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2974 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2975 @end deffn
2976
2977 @quotation Note
2978 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2979 which are not currently documented here.
2980 @end quotation
2981
2982 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2983 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2984 No arguments: print status.
2985 @end deffn
2986
2987 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2988 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2989 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2990
2991 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2992 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2993 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2994 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2995 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2996 configuration on exit.
2997
2998 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2999 pinout.
3000
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @section Transport Configuration
3004 @cindex Transport
3005 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3006 and the debug adapter you are using,
3007 several transports may be available to
3008 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3009 @deffn Command {transport list}
3010 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3011 version of OpenOCD.
3012 @end deffn
3013
3014 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3015 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3016
3017 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3018 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3019 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3020 adapter's driver).
3021
3022 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3023 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3024 supported by the debug adapter.
3025
3026 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3027 transport, if any.
3028 @end deffn
3029
3030 @subsection JTAG Transport
3031 @cindex JTAG
3032 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3033 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3034 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3035 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3036 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3037 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3038
3039 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3040 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3041 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3042 hla_jtag}.
3043
3044 @subsection SWD Transport
3045 @cindex SWD
3046 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3047 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3048 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3049 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3050 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3051 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3052 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3053
3054 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3055 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3056 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3057 hla_swd}.
3058
3059 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3060 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3061 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3062 expected to change.
3063 @end deffn
3064 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3065 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3066 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3067 No parameters: displays current settings.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @subsection SPI Transport
3071 @cindex SPI
3072 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3073 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3074 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3075 solution for flash programming.
3076
3077 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3078 @section JTAG Speed
3079 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3080 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3081 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3082 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3083 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3084 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3085 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3086 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3087 power management software that may be active.
3088
3089 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3090 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3091 target event handler.
3092 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3093 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3094 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3095 sets up those clocks).
3096 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3097 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3098 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3099 in the target config file.
3100 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3101 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3102 config file instead.
3103 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3104 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3105 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3106
3107 @example
3108 jtag_rclk 3000
3109 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3110 @end example
3111
3112 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3113 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3114 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3115 may not be the fastest solution.
3116
3117 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3118 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3119 which support adaptive clocking.
3120
3121 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3122 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3123 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3124 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3125 than the speed specified.
3126
3127 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3128 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3129 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3130 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3131
3132 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3133 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3134 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3135 JTAG clocking after setup.
3136 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3137 If the interface device can not
3138 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3142 @cindex adaptive clocking
3143 @cindex RTCK
3144 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3145 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3146 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3147 @example
3148 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3149 jtag_rclk 3000
3150 @end example
3151 @end defun
3152
3153 @node Reset Configuration
3154 @chapter Reset Configuration
3155 @cindex Reset Configuration
3156
3157 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3158 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3159 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3160 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3161 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3162 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3163 Please see the various board files for examples.
3164
3165 @quotation Note
3166 To maintainers and integrators:
3167 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3168 Normally the board configuration file
3169 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3170 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3171
3172 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3173 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3174 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3175 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3176 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3177 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3178 @end quotation
3179
3180 @section Types of Reset
3181
3182 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3183 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3184 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3185
3186 @itemize @bullet
3187 @item
3188 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3189 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3190 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3191 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3192 @item
3193 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3194 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3195 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3196 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3197 @item
3198 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3199 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3200 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3201 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3202 @item
3203 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3204 several other types of reset.
3205 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3206 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3207 There may be individual module resets.
3208 @end itemize
3209
3210 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3211 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3212 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3213 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3214 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3215 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3216 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3217 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3218 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3219
3220 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3221 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3222
3223 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3224 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3225 common issues are:
3226
3227 @itemize @bullet
3228
3229 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3230 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3231 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3232 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3233 when either of those signals is not connected.
3234 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3235 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3236 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3237 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3238
3239 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3240 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3241 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3242 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3243
3244 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3245 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3246 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3247 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3248 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3249 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3250 hardware debouncing.
3251 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3252 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3253
3254 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3255 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3256 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3257 to use push/pull output drivers.
3258 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3259 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3260 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3261 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3262
3263 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3264 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3265 issues (not limited to errata).
3266 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3267 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3268 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3269 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3270 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3271 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3272 @end itemize
3273
3274 There can also be other issues.
3275 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3276 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3277 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3278 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3279 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3280 Agreement (NDA).
3281
3282 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3283 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3284 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3285
3286 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3287 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3288
3289 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3290
3291 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3292 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3293 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3294 allowing it to be deasserted.
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3298 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3299 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3300 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3301 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3302 @end deffn
3303
3304 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3305 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3306 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3307 allowing it to be deasserted.
3308 @end deffn
3309
3310 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3311 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3312 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3313 @end deffn
3314
3315 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3316 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3317 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3318 configuration scripts.
3319
3320 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3321 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3322 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3323 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3324 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3325 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3326 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3327 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3328
3329 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3330 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3331 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3332 -- may be specified at a time.
3333 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3334 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3335 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3336 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3337 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3338
3339 @itemize
3340 @item
3341 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3342 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3343 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3344 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3345 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3346
3347 @quotation Tip
3348 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3349 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3350 @end quotation
3351
3352 @item
3353 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3354 signal implementations.
3355 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3356 indicating everything behaves normally.
3357 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3358 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3359 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3360 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3361 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3362 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3363 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3364
3365 @item
3366 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3367 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3368 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3369 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3370 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3371 while SRST is asserted.
3372 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3373 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3374
3375 @item
3376 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3377 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3378 is required to use this option.
3379 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3380 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3381 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3382 be asserted before any target connection.
3383 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3384 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3385 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3386 @end itemize
3387
3388 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3389 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3390 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3391 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3392 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3393
3394 @itemize
3395 @item
3396 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3397 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3398 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3399 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3400
3401 @item
3402 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3403 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3404 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3405 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3406 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3407 @end itemize
3408 @end deffn
3409
3410 @section Custom Reset Handling
3411 @cindex events
3412
3413 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3414 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3415 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3416 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3417 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3418 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3419
3420 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3421 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3422 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3423 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3424 want to reset everything at once.
3425
3426 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3427 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3428 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3429 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3430 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3431 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3432 needs special attention.
3433
3434 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3435 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3436 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3437 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3438 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3439 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3440 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3441 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3442
3443 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3444 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3445 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3446 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3447 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3448
3449 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3450 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3451 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3452 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3453 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3454 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3455 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3456 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3457 or potentially some other value.
3458
3459 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3460 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3461 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3462 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3463 (or their associated targets)
3464 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3465
3466 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3467 they return.
3468 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3469 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3473 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3474 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3475 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3476 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3477 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3478 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3479 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3480 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3481 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3482 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3483 @end deffn
3484
3485 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3486 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3487 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3488 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3489 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3490 @end deffn
3491
3492
3493 @node TAP Declaration
3494 @chapter TAP Declaration
3495 @cindex TAP declaration
3496 @cindex TAP configuration
3497
3498 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3499 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3500
3501 @itemize @bullet
3502 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3503 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3504 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3505 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3506 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3507 start running that code.
3508 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3509 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3510 and missing connections.
3511 @end itemize
3512
3513 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3514 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3515 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3516 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3517 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3518
3519 @section Scan Chains
3520 @cindex scan chain
3521
3522 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3523 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3524 They also need to be added to
3525 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3526 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3527 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3528 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3529 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3530 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3531 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3532 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3533
3534 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3535 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3536 command, presented in the next chapter.
3537 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3538 debugging targets.)
3539 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3540
3541 @verbatim
3542 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3543 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3544 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3545 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3546 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3547 @end verbatim
3548
3549 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3550 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3551 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3552 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3553 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3554 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3555 until they are told to do so.
3556
3557 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3558 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3559 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3560 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3561
3562 @example
3563 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3564 @end example
3565
3566 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3567 by a given chip.
3568 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3569 and so forth.
3570 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3571 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3572 both inside a single chip and between them.
3573 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3574
3575 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3576 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3577 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3578 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3579 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3580 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3581 includes commands something like this:
3582
3583 @example
3584 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3585 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3586 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3587 @end example
3588
3589 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3590 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3591 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3592
3593 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3594 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3595 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3596 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3597 @example
3598 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3599 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3600 @}
3601 @end example
3602 @end deffn
3603
3604 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3605 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3606 and their status.
3607 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3608 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3609 but systems with a JTAG router can
3610 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3611 @end deffn
3612
3613 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3614 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3615
3616 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3617 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3618
3619 @section TAP Names
3620 @cindex dotted name
3621
3622 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3623 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3624 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3625 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3626 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3627 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3628 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3629 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3630
3631 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3632 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3633 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3634
3635 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3636
3637 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3638 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3639 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3640 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3641
3642 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3643 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3644 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3645 overridable.
3646
3647 @cindex TAP naming convention
3648 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3649 and should follow this convention:
3650
3651 @itemize @bullet
3652 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3653 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3654 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3655 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3656 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3657 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3658 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3659 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3660 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3661 with a single TAP;
3662 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3663 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3664 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3665 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3666 @end itemize
3667
3668 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3669
3670 @itemize @bullet
3671 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3672 @*The length in bits of the
3673 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3674 @end itemize
3675
3676 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3677
3678 @itemize @bullet
3679 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3680 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3681 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3682 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3683 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3684 (the TAP is linked in).
3685 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3686 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3687 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3688 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3689 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3690 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3691 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3692 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3693 values that were found but not included in the list.
3694
3695 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3696 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3697 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3698 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3699 hardware to find these values.
3700 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3701 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3702 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3703 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3704 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3705 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3706 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3707 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3708 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3709 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3710 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3711 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3712 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3713 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3714 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3715 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3716 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3717 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3718 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3719 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3720 @end itemize
3721 @end deffn
3722
3723 @section Other TAP commands
3724
3725 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3726 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3727 At this writing this TAP attribute
3728 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3729 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3730 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3731 See the next section for information about the available events.
3732
3733 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3734 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3735 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3736 @end deffn
3737
3738 @section TAP Events
3739 @cindex events
3740 @cindex TAP events
3741
3742 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3743 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3744 The other applies to debugger targets,
3745 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3746
3747 The TAP events currently defined are:
3748
3749 @itemize @bullet
3750 @item @b{post-reset}
3751 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3752 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3753 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3754 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3755 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3756
3757 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3758 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3759 of any particular target.
3760 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3761 @item @b{setup}
3762 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3763 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3764 @item @b{tap-disable}
3765 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3766 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3767 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3768 @item @b{tap-enable}
3769 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3770 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3771 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3772 @end itemize
3773
3774 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3775 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3776 contents to be accurate), you might:
3777
3778 @example
3779 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3780 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3781 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3782 @}
3783 @end example
3784
3785
3786 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3787 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3788 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3789 @cindex jrc
3790
3791 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3792 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3793 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3794 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3795 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3796
3797 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3798 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3799 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3800 be visible.
3801 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3802 ignores, such as:
3803
3804 @itemize
3805 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3806 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3807 TAPs receive new instructions.
3808 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3809 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3810 @end itemize
3811
3812 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3813 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3814 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3815 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3816
3817 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3818 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3819
3820 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3821 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3822 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3823 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3824 should define TAP event handlers using
3825 code that looks something like this:
3826
3827 @example
3828 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3829 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3830 @}
3831 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3832 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3833 @}
3834 @end example
3835
3836 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3837
3838 @example
3839 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3840 @end example
3841
3842 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3843 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3844 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3845 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3846
3847 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3848 If necessary, disables the tap
3849 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3850 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3851 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3852 and "0" if it is disabled.
3853 @end deffn
3854
3855 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3856 If necessary, enables the tap
3857 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3858 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3859 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3860 and "0" if it is disabled.
3861 @end deffn
3862
3863 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3864 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3865 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3866 and "0" if it is disabled.
3867
3868 @quotation Note
3869 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3870 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3871 @end quotation
3872 @end deffn
3873
3874 @anchor{autoprobing}
3875 @section Autoprobing
3876 @cindex autoprobe
3877 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3878
3879 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3880 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3881 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3882 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3883
3884 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3885 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3886 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3887 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3888 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3889 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3890 right when they come out of reset).
3891
3892 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3893
3894 @example
3895 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3896 reset_config trst_and_srst
3897 jtag_rclk 8
3898 @end example
3899
3900 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3901 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3902
3903 @enumerate
3904 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3905 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3906 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3907 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3908 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3909 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3910 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3911 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3912 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3913 that is discovered.
3914 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3915 register, it will report it.
3916 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3917 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3918 @end enumerate
3919
3920 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3921 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3922 that's a bit more complex:
3923
3924 @example
3925 clock speed 8 kHz
3926 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3927 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3928 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3929 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3930 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3931 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3932 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3933 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3934 @end example
3935
3936 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3937 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3938 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3939 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3940 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3941 and so forth.
3942
3943 @node CPU Configuration
3944 @chapter CPU Configuration
3945 @cindex GDB target
3946
3947 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3948 You can also access these targets without GDB
3949 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3950 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3951 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3952 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3953
3954 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3955 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3956
3957 @section Target List
3958 @cindex target, current
3959 @cindex target, list
3960
3961 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3962 where each member has a name.
3963 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3964 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3965 (plural!) command.
3966 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3967 look like with more than one:
3968 @verbatim
3969 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3970 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3971 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3972 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3973 @end verbatim
3974
3975 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3976 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3977 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3978 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3979 space seen by that current target.
3980 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3981 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3982 are examples; and there are many more.
3983
3984 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3985
3986 @deffn Command {target current}
3987 Returns the name of the current target.
3988 @end deffn
3989
3990 @deffn Command {target names}
3991 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3992 @example
3993 foreach t [target names] @{
3994 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3995 @}
3996 @end example
3997 @end deffn
3998
3999 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4000 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4001
4002 @deffn Command targets [name]
4003 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4004 command names are singular.}
4005
4006 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4007 targets in a user friendly form.
4008
4009 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4010 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4011 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4012 @end deffn
4013
4014 @section Target CPU Types
4015 @cindex target type
4016 @cindex CPU type
4017
4018 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4019 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4020 when calling @command{target create}.
4021 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4022 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4023 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4024 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4025 what core-specific commands may be available
4026 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4027 and more.
4028
4029 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4030 since there's a command to list them.
4031
4032 @anchor{targettypes}
4033 @deffn Command {target types}
4034 Lists all supported target types.
4035 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4036
4037 @itemize @bullet
4038 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4039 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4040 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4041 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4042 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4043 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4044 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4045 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4046 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4047 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4048 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4049 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4050 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4051 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4052 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4053 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4054 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4055 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4056 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4057 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4058 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4059 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4060 @itemize @minus
4061 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4062 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4063 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4064 @end itemize
4065 And two debug interfaces cores:
4066 @itemize @minus
4067 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4068 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4069 @end itemize
4070 @end itemize
4071 @end deffn
4072
4073 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4074 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4075 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4076 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4077 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4078 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4079 reflect design generations;
4080 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4081 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4082
4083 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4084 @section Target Configuration
4085
4086 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4087 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4088 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4089 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4090 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4091
4092 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4093 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4094 optional parts.
4095 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4096 command, created as part of target creation.
4097
4098 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4099 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4100 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4101 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4102 to be much more board-specific.
4103 The key steps you use might look something like this
4104
4105 @example
4106 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4107 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4108 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4109 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4110 @end example
4111
4112 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4113 on-chip SRAM.
4114 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4115 writes to target memory;
4116 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4117 GDB memory checksumming;
4118 and more.
4119
4120 @quotation Warning
4121 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4122 inaccessible when application code
4123 (such as an operating system)
4124 enables or disables the MMU.
4125 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4126 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4127 easy access to other addresses needed.
4128 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4129 @end quotation
4130
4131 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4132 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4133 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4134 controllers.
4135 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4136 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4137 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4138
4139 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4140 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4141 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4142 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4143 purposes including additional configuration.
4144
4145 @itemize @bullet
4146 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4147 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4148 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4149 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4150
4151 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4152 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4153 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4154 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4155 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4156 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4157 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4158
4159 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4160 @end itemize
4161 @end deffn
4162
4163 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4164 The options accepted by this command may also be
4165 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4166 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4167 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4168
4169 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4170 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4171 and changing its endianness.
4172
4173 @itemize @bullet
4174
4175 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4176 used to access this target.
4177
4178 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4179 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4180
4181 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4182 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4183 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4184 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4185 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4186 same event name assigns only one handler.
4187
4188 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4189 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4190 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4191 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4192 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4193 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4194 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4195
4196 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4197 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4198 or virtual address is being used.
4199
4200 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4201 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4202
4203 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4204 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4205 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4206 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4207 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4208
4209 @anchor{rtostype}
4210 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4211 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4212 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4213 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4214
4215 @end itemize
4216 @end deffn
4217
4218 @section Other $target_name Commands
4219 @cindex object command
4220
4221 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4222 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4223
4224 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4225 Once a button is created a button
4226 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4227 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4228 configure it like this:
4229
4230 @example
4231 # Create
4232 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4233 # Modify
4234 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4235 # Query
4236 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4237 # Report
4238 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4239 @end example
4240
4241 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4242 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4243
4244 @example
4245 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4246 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4247 @end example
4248
4249 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4250
4251 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4252 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4253 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4254 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4255 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4256 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4257 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4258 They are not otherwise documented here.
4259 @end deffn
4260
4261 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4262 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4263 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4264 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4265 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4266 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4267 the target side uses raw memory.
4268
4269 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4270 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4271 The script orientation comes from working with data
4272 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4273 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4274 and neither store nor return those values.
4275
4276 @itemize
4277 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4278 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4279 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4280 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4281 @end itemize
4282 @end deffn
4283
4284 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4285 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4286 @command{$target_name configure}
4287 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4288 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4289 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4290 There are a few special cases:
4291
4292 @itemize @bullet
4293 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4294 event named @var{event_name}.
4295 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4296 two parameters.
4297 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4298 This is a special case because this is set using
4299 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4300 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4301 @end itemize
4302
4303 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4304 all the targets you might use something like this:
4305
4306 @example
4307 foreach name [target names] @{
4308 set y [$name cget -endian]
4309 set z [$name cget -type]
4310 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4311 $x $name $y $z]
4312 @}
4313 @end example
4314 @end deffn
4315
4316 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4317 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4318 Displays the current target state:
4319 @code{debug-running},
4320 @code{halted},
4321 @code{reset},
4322 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4323 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4324 @end deffn
4325
4326 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4327 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4328 currently associated with this target.
4329 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4330 @end deffn
4331
4332 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4333 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4334 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4335 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4336 @end deffn
4337
4338 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4339 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4340 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4341 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4342 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4343 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4344 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4345 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4346 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4347 @end deffn
4348
4349 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4350 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4351 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4352 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4353 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4354 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4355 @end deffn
4356
4357 @anchor{targetevents}
4358 @section Target Events
4359 @cindex target events
4360 @cindex events
4361 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4362 For example:
4363 @itemize @bullet
4364 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4365 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4366 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4367 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4368 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4369 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4370 to set up system clocks or
4371 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4372 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4373 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4374 @end itemize
4375
4376 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4377 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4378 @command{target create ... -event}.
4379
4380 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4381 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4382 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4383
4384 @example
4385 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4386 echo "Reset..."
4387 reset halt
4388 @}
4389 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4390 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4391 echo "Reset..."
4392 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4393 # we need a reset init.
4394 reset init
4395 @}
4396 @end example
4397
4398 The following target events are defined:
4399
4400 @itemize @bullet
4401 @item @b{debug-halted}
4402 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4403 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4404 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4405 @item @b{early-halted}
4406 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4407 @item @b{examine-start}
4408 @* Before target examine is called.
4409 @item @b{examine-end}
4410 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4411 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4412 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4413 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4414 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4415 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4416 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4417 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4418 @* When GDB disconnects
4419 @item @b{gdb-end}
4420 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4421 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4422 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4423 @code{reset init})
4424 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4425 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4426 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4427 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4428 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4429 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4430 @item @b{gdb-start}
4431 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4432 @item @b{halted}
4433 @* The target has halted
4434 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4435 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4436 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4437 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4438 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4439 @item @b{reset-assert}
4440 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4441 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4442 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4443 it instead of asserting SRST.
4444 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4445 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4446 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4447 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4448 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4449 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4450 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4451 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4452 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4453 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4454 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4455 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4456 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4457 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4458 released on the scan chain.
4459 @item @b{reset-end}
4460 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4461 @ignore
4462 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4463 @* Currently not used
4464 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4465 @* Currently not used
4466 @end ignore
4467 @item @b{reset-init}
4468 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4469 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4470
4471 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4472 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4473 multiplexing, and so on.
4474 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4475 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4476 @item @b{reset-start}
4477 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4478 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4479
4480 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4481 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4482 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4483 @ignore
4484 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4485 @* Currently not used
4486 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4487 @* Currently not used
4488 @end ignore
4489 @item @b{resume-start}
4490 @* Before any target is resumed
4491 @item @b{resume-end}
4492 @* After all targets have resumed
4493 @item @b{resumed}
4494 @* Target has resumed
4495 @item @b{trace-config}
4496 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4497 @end itemize
4498
4499 @node Flash Commands
4500 @chapter Flash Commands
4501
4502 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4503 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4504 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4505 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4506 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4507 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4508 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4509 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4510 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4511
4512 Flash Steps:
4513 @enumerate
4514 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4515 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4516 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4517 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4518 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4519 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4520 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4521 @item GDB Flashing
4522 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4523 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4524 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4525 @end enumerate
4526
4527 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4528 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4529 so that it can't boot.
4530 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4531 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4532
4533 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4534 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4535 @cindex flash configuration
4536
4537 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4538 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4539 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4540 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4541 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4542 see the driver-specific documentation.
4543
4544 @itemize @bullet
4545 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4546 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4547 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4548 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4549 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4550 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4551 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4552 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4553 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4554 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4555 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4556 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4557 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4558 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4559 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4560 commands to the flash controller.
4561 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4562 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4563 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4564 for more information.
4565 @end itemize
4566 @quotation Note
4567 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4568 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4569 @end quotation
4570 @end deffn
4571
4572 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4573 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4574 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4575 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4576 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4577 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4578 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4579 @end deffn
4580
4581 @deffn Command {flash list}
4582 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4583 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4584 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4585 @end deffn
4586
4587 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4588 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4589 depends on the flash type.
4590 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4591 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4592 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4593 but most don't bother.
4594 @end deffn
4595
4596 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4597 @cindex flash erasing
4598 @cindex flash reading
4599 @cindex flash writing
4600 @cindex flash programming
4601 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4602
4603 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4604 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4605 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4606 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4607 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4608
4609 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4610 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4611 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4612 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4613 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4614
4615 @quotation Note
4616 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4617 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4618 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4619 back to a flash bank.
4620 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4621 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4622 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4623 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4624 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4625 @end quotation
4626
4627 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4628 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4629 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4630 disabled first.
4631 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4632 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4633 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4634
4635 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4636 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4637 up to and including @var{last}.
4638 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4639 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4640 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4641 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4642 @end deffn
4643
4644 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4645 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4646 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4647 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4648 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4649 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4650 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4651 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4652 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4653 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4654 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4655 before erase starts.
4656 @end deffn
4657
4658 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4659 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4660 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4661 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4662 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4663 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4664 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4665 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4666 before issuing this command.
4667 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4668 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4669 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4670 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4671 @end deffn
4672 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4673
4674 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4675 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4676 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4677 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4678 @end deffn
4679
4680 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4681 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4682 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4683 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4684 @end deffn
4685
4686 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4687 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4688 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4689 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4693 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4694 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4695 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4696 to the base address for each section in the image.
4697 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4698 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4699 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4700 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4701 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4702 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4703 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4704 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4705 each image section.
4706
4707 @quotation Warning
4708 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4709 data you want to preserve.
4710 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4711 sections might be erased with no notice.
4712 @itemize
4713 @item
4714 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4715 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4716 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4717 @item
4718 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4719 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4720 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4721 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4722 @end itemize
4723 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4724 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4725 @end quotation
4726
4727 @end deffn
4728
4729 @section Other Flash commands
4730 @cindex flash protection
4731
4732 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4733 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4734 and display that status.
4735 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4736 @end deffn
4737
4738 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4739 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4740 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4741 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4742 and possibly stale information.
4743 @end deffn
4744
4745 @anchor{flashprotect}
4746 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4747 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4748 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4749 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4750 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4751 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4752 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4756 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4757 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4758 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @anchor{program}
4762 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4763 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4764 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4765 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4769 @section Flash Driver List
4770 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4771 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4772 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4773
4774 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4775 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4776 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4777
4778 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4779
4780 @itemize
4781 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4782 @end itemize
4783
4784 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4785 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4786 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4787 @example
4788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4789 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4790 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4791 @end example
4792 @end deffn
4793
4794 @subsection External Flash
4795
4796 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4797 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4798 @cindex CFI
4799 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4800 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4801 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4802 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4803 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4804 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4805 configure a bus and its timings), or
4806 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4807 on the flash chip.
4808 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4809 speed up operation.
4810
4811 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4812
4813 @itemize
4814 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4815 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4816 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4817 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4818 @end itemize
4819
4820 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4821 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4822
4823 @example
4824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4825 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4826 @end example
4827
4828 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4829 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4830 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4831
4832 @example
4833 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4834 @end example
4835
4836 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4837 @end deffn
4838
4839 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4840 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4841 @cindex SPI
4842 @cindex jtagspi
4843 @cindex bscan_spi
4844 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4845 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4846 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4847 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4848 accessed through JTAG.
4849
4850 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4851 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4852 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4853 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4854 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4855 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4856
4857 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4858 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4859 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4860 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4861 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4862 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4863 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4864 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4865
4866 @itemize
4867 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4868 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4869 @var{USER1} instruction.
4870 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4871 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4872 @end itemize
4873
4874 @example
4875 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4876 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4877 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4878 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4879 @end example
4880 @end deffn
4881
4882 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4883 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4884 @cindex SPIFI
4885 @cindex lpcspifi
4886 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4887 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4888 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4889
4890 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4891 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4892 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4893 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4894 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4895
4896 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4897 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4898 are configured by the driver.
4899
4900 @example
4901 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4902 @end example
4903
4904 @end deffn
4905
4906 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4907 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4908 @cindex SMI
4909 @cindex stmsmi
4910 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4911 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4912 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4913 SPI flash devices.
4914 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4915 flash devices can be connected.
4916
4917 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4918 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4919 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4920 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4921 the flash content.
4922
4923 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4924 to identify the memory bank.
4925 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4926 flash size, are detected automatically.
4927
4928 @example
4929 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4930 @end example
4931
4932 @end deffn
4933
4934 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4935 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4936 Microcontroller platform.
4937
4938 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4939 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4940
4941 @example
4942 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4943 @end example
4944
4945 @end deffn
4946
4947 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4948
4949 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4950 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4951 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4952 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4953 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4954 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4955
4956 @example
4957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4958 @end example
4959 @end deffn
4960
4961 @anchor{at91samd}
4962 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4963 @cindex at91samd
4964 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
4965 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
4966 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4967
4968 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4969 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4970 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4971 processor to be halted.
4972 @end deffn
4973
4974 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4975 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4976 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4977 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4978 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4979 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4980
4981 @example
4982 at91samd set-security enable
4983 @end example
4984 @end deffn
4985
4986 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4987 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4988 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4989 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4990 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4991 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4992 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4993 in order to disable this feature.
4994
4995 @example
4996 at91samd eeprom
4997 at91samd eeprom 1024
4998 @end example
4999 @end deffn
5000
5001 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5002 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5003 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5004 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5005 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5006 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5007
5008 @example
5009 at91samd bootloader
5010 at91samd bootloader 16384
5011 @end example
5012 @end deffn
5013
5014 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5015 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5016 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5017 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5018 @end deffn
5019
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @anchor{at91sam3}
5023 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5024 @cindex at91sam3
5025 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5026 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5027 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5028 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5029 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5030 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5031 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5032 chips are confirmed.}
5033
5034 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5035 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5036 the following fixed locations:
5037
5038 @example
5039 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5040 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5041 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5042 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5043 @end example
5044
5045 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5046 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5047 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5048
5049 @itemize
5050 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5051 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5052 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5053 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5054 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5055 @end itemize
5056
5057 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5058
5059 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5060 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5061 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5062 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5063 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5064 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5065 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5066
5067 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5068 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5069 @end deffn
5070
5071 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5072 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5073 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5074 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5075 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5076 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5077 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5078 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5079 @end deffn
5080
5081 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5082 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5083 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5084 @end deffn
5085 @end deffn
5086
5087 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5088 @cindex at91sam4
5089 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5090 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5091 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5092 @end deffn
5093
5094 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5095 @cindex at91sam4l
5096 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5097 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5098 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5099
5100 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5101 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5102 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5103 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5104 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5105 @end deffn
5106 @end deffn
5107
5108 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5109 @cindex atsamv
5110 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5111 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5112 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5113 @end deffn
5114
5115 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5116 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5117 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5118 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5119 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5120
5121 @example
5122 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5123 @end example
5124
5125 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5126 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5127
5128 @itemize
5129 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5130 @item @var{banks}
5131 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5132 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5133 @item @var{pages_size}
5134 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5135 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5136 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5137 @end itemize
5138
5139 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5140 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5141 will be autoconfigured.
5142 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5143
5144 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5145 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5146 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5147 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5148 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5149
5150 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5151 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5152 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5153 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5154 are not truly general purpose).
5155 @quotation Note
5156 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5157 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5158 @end quotation
5159 @end deffn
5160 @end deffn
5161
5162 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5163 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5164 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5165 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5166 @end deffn
5167
5168 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5169 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5170 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5171 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5172 autoconfigures itself.
5173 @example
5174 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5175 @end example
5176 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5177 supported.}
5178 @end deffn
5179
5180 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5181 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5182 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5183 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5184 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5185 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5186 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5187
5188 @example
5189 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5190 @end example
5191 @end deffn
5192
5193 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5194 @cindex kinetis
5195 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5196 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5197 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5198 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5199
5200 @example
5201 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5202 @end example
5203
5204 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5205 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5206 @end deffn
5207
5208 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5209 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5210 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5211 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5212 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5216 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5217 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5218 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5219 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5220
5221 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5222 Program Partition command.
5223
5224 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5225 Reset the device after partition setting.
5226
5227 Show partition size:
5228 @example
5229 kinetis nvm_partition info
5230 @end example
5231
5232 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5233 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5234 @example
5235 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5236 @end example
5237
5238 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5239 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5240 @example
5241 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5242 @end example
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5246 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5247 Command disables watchdog timer.
5248 @end deffn
5249 @end deffn
5250
5251 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5252 @cindex kinetis_ke
5253 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5254 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5255 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5256 autoconfigures itself.
5257
5258 @example
5259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5260 @end example
5261
5262 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5263 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5264 @end deffn
5265
5266 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5267 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5268 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5269 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5270 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5271 @end deffn
5272
5273 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5274 Command disables watchdog timer.
5275 @end deffn
5276 @end deffn
5277
5278 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5279 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5280 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5281 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5282 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5283 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5284 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5285 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5286 characters) ignored.
5287
5288 @example
5289 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5290 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5291 @end example
5292 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5293 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5294 @end deffn
5295
5296 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5297 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5298 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5299 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5300 microcontroller families from NXP.
5301
5302 @quotation Note
5303 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5304 driver:
5305 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5306 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5307 @end quotation
5308
5309 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5310 which must appear in the following order:
5311
5312 @itemize
5313 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5314 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5315 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5316 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5317 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5318 LPC43x[2357])
5319 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5320 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5321 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5322 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5323 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5324 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5325 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5326 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5327 at which the core is running
5328 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5329 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5330 @quotation Note
5331 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5332 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5333 However, if you do provide it,
5334 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5335 @end quotation
5336 @end itemize
5337
5338 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5339
5340 @example
5341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5342 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5343 @end example
5344
5345 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5346 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5347 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5348 @end deffn
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5352 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5353 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5354 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5355 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5356 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5357
5358 @example
5359 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5360 @end example
5361 @end deffn
5362
5363 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5364 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5365 from NXP.
5366
5367 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5368 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5369 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5370 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5371 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5372 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5373 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5374 you start the PLL.
5375
5376 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5377
5378 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5379 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5380 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5381
5382 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5383 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5384 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5385 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5386 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5387 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5388 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5389
5390 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5391 @example
5392 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5393 @end example
5394
5395 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5396 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5397 @code{flash banks} command.
5398
5399 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5400 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5401 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5402 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5403 a known signature.
5404 Example:
5405 @example
5406 lpc2900 signature 0
5407 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5408 @end example
5409 @end deffn
5410
5411 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5412 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5413 saves it to a file in binary format.
5414 Example:
5415 @example
5416 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5417 @end example
5418 @end deffn
5419
5420 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5421 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5422 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5423 command:
5424
5425 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5426 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5427 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5428 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5429
5430 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5431 Example:
5432 @example
5433 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5434 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5435 @end example
5436 @end deffn
5437
5438 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5439 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5440 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5441 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5442 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5443 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5444 912 bytes.
5445 @quotation Attention
5446 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5447 @end quotation
5448 Example:
5449 @example
5450 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5451 @end example
5452 @end deffn
5453
5454 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5455 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5456 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5457 after the next power cycle.
5458 @quotation Attention
5459 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5460 @end quotation
5461 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5462 Example:
5463 @example
5464 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5465 flash info 0
5466 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5467 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5468 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5469 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5470 @end example
5471 @end deffn
5472
5473 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5474 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5475 effective after the next power cycle.
5476 @quotation Attention
5477 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5478 @end quotation
5479 Examples:
5480 @example
5481 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5482 @end example
5483 @end deffn
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5487 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5488 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5489 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5490
5491 @example
5492 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5493 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5494 @end example
5495
5496 @itemize @bullet
5497 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5498 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5499 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5500 @end itemize
5501
5502 Example usage:
5503 @example
5504 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5505 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5506 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5507 @} else @{
5508 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5509 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5510 @}
5511 @end example
5512 @end deffn
5513
5514 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5515 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5516 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5517 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5518 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5519 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5520 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5521 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5522 also have division into regions: main and info.
5523 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5524 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5525
5526 @example
5527 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5528 @end example
5529
5530 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5531
5532 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5533 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5534 @end deffn
5535
5536 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5537 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5538 @end deffn
5539
5540 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5541 Erase all userflash including info region.
5542 @end deffn
5543
5544 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5545 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5546 @end deffn
5547
5548 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5549 Check sectors protect.
5550 @end deffn
5551
5552 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5553 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5554 @end deffn
5555
5556 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5557 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5558 @end deffn
5559
5560 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5561 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5562 @end deffn
5563
5564 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5565 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5566 @end deffn
5567
5568 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5569 Show information about flash driver.
5570 @end deffn
5571
5572 @end deffn
5573
5574 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5575 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5576 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5577
5578 @example
5579 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5580 @end example
5581
5582 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5583
5584 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5585 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5586 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5587 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5588 code.
5589 @end deffn
5590
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5594 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5595 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5596
5597 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5598 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5599 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5600 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5601
5602 @example
5603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5604 @end example
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5608 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5609 and integrate flash memory.
5610
5611 @example
5612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5613 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5614 @end example
5615
5616 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5617 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5618 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5619 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5620 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5621 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5622 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5623 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5624 @end deffn
5625 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5626 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5627 This will remove any Code Protection.
5628 @end deffn
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5632 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5633 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5634 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5635 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5636
5637 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5638 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5639
5640 @example
5641 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5642 @end example
5643
5644 psoc4-specific commands
5645 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5646 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5647
5648 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5649 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5650
5651 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5652 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5653 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5654
5655 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5656 @end deffn
5657
5658 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5659 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5660
5661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5662 @end deffn
5663 @end deffn
5664
5665 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5666 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5667 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5668 and SWD interface.
5669 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5670 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5671
5672 @example
5673 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5674 @end example
5675
5676 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5677
5678 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5679 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5680 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5681 @end deffn
5682
5683 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5684 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5685 @end deffn
5686 @end deffn
5687
5688 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5689 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5690 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5691 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5692 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5693 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5694 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5695 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5696
5697 @example
5698 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5699 @end example
5700
5701 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5702 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5703 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5704 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5705 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5706 disabled.
5707
5708 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5709 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5710 @quotation Warning
5711 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5712 applied to all of them.
5713 @end quotation
5714 @end deffn
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5718 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5719 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5720 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5721 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5722
5723 @example
5724 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5725 @end example
5726
5727 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5728 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5729 the flash driver.
5730
5731 @example
5732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5733 @end example
5734
5735 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5736 as per the following example.
5737 @example
5738 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5739 @end example
5740
5741 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5742 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5743 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5744 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5745 are defined:
5746
5747 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5748 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5749 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5750 @end deffn
5751
5752 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5753 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5754 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5755 @end deffn
5756
5757 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5758 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5759 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5760 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5761 @end deffn
5762
5763 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5764 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5765 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5766 @end deffn
5767 @end deffn
5768
5769 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5770 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5771 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5772 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5773 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5774
5775 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5776 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5777 the flash driver.
5778
5779 @example
5780 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5781 @end example
5782
5783 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5784
5785 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5786 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5787 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5788 @end deffn
5789
5790 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5791 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5792 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5793 @end deffn
5794 @end deffn
5795
5796 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5797 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5798 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5799 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5800 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5801
5802 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5803 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5804 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5805 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5806 second bank.
5807
5808 @example
5809 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5810 @end example
5811
5812 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5813
5814 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5815 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5816 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5817 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5818 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5819 @end deffn
5820 @end deffn
5821
5822 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5823 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5824 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5825 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5826 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5827
5828 @example
5829 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5830 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5831 @end example
5832
5833 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5834 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5835 for the specified flash bank.
5836 @end deffn
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5840 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5841 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5842 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5843 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5844
5845 @example
5846 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5847 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5848 @end example
5849
5850 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5851 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5852 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5853
5854 @itemize @bullet
5855 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5856 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5857 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5858 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5859 @end itemize
5860 @end deffn
5861
5862 @end deffn
5863
5864 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5865 @cindex str9xpec
5866
5867 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5868 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5869 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5870 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5871
5872 Here is some background info to help
5873 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5874 the str9:
5875 @enumerate
5876 @item
5877 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5878 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5879 @item
5880 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5881 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5882 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5883 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5884 @end enumerate
5885
5886 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5887 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5888 configured for flash bank 0.
5889 @example
5890 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5891 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5892 jtag_reset 0 1
5893 # turn off target polling
5894 poll off
5895 # disable str9 core
5896 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5897 # read option bytes
5898 str9xpec options_read 0
5899 # re-enable str9 core
5900 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5901 poll on
5902 reset halt
5903 @end example
5904 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5905 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5906 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5907 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5908
5909 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5910
5911 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5912 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5913 @end deffn
5914
5915 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5916 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5917 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5918 @end deffn
5919
5920 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5921 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5922 erase the device.
5923 @end deffn
5924
5925 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5926 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5927 @end deffn
5928
5929 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5930 Configure str9 boot bank.
5931 @end deffn
5932
5933 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5934 Configure str9 lvd source.
5935 @end deffn
5936
5937 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5938 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5942 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5943 @end deffn
5944
5945 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5946 Read str9 option bytes.
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5950 Write str9 option bytes.
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5954 unlock str9 device.
5955 @end deffn
5956
5957 @end deffn
5958
5959 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5960 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5961 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5962 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5963
5964 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5965
5966 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5967 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5968 @end deffn
5969
5970 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5971 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5972 @end deffn
5973
5974 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5975 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5976 the flash clock.
5977 @end deffn
5978 @end deffn
5979
5980 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
5981 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
5982 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5983
5984 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
5985
5986 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
5987 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
5988 @end deffn
5989
5990 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
5991 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
5992 @end deffn
5993
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @section NAND Flash Commands
5997 @cindex NAND
5998
5999 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6000 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6001 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6002
6003 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6004 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6005 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6006 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6007 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6008 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6009
6010 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6011 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6012 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6013 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6014 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6015 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6016 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6017 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6018 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6019 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6020
6021 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6022 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6023 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6024 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6025 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6026 every 512 bytes of data.
6027
6028 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6029 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6030 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6031 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6032 ECC mode is used.
6033
6034 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6035 @enumerate
6036 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6037 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6038 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6039 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6040 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6041 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6042 to access that device.
6043 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6044 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6045 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6046 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6047 de-brick a board.
6048 @end enumerate
6049
6050 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6051 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6052 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6053 are only 32 bits wide.
6054 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6055 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6056 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6057 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6058
6059 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6060 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6061 @cindex NAND configuration
6062
6063 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6064 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6065 OpenOCD has initialized.
6066
6067 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6068 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6069 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6070 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6071 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6072 they were a single (larger) device.
6073 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6074 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6075
6076 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6077 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6078 configuration files, not interactively.
6079
6080 @itemize @bullet
6081 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6082 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6083 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6084 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6085 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6086 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6087 commands to the NAND controller.
6088 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6089 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6090 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6091 for more information.
6092 @end itemize
6093 @end deffn
6094
6095 @deffn Command {nand list}
6096 Prints a summary of each device declared
6097 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6098 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6099 @example
6100 > nand list
6101 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6102 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6103 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6104 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6105 >
6106 @end example
6107 @end deffn
6108
6109 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6110 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6111 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6112 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6113 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6114 it with most other NAND commands.
6115 @end deffn
6116
6117 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6118
6119 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6120 @cindex NAND reading
6121 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6122 starting at the specified offset.
6123 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6124
6125 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6126 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6127
6128 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6129 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6130 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6131
6132 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6133 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6134 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6135 method which handled that error correction.
6136
6137 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6138 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6139 @itemize @bullet
6140 @item no oob_* parameter
6141 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6142 @item @code{oob_raw}
6143 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6144 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6145 spare areas associated with each data page.
6146 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6147 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6148 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6149 @item @code{oob_only}
6150 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6151 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6152 spare areas associated with each data page.
6153 @end itemize
6154 @end deffn
6155
6156 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6157 @cindex NAND erasing
6158 @cindex NAND programming
6159 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6160 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6161 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6162 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6163 If those parameters are not specified,
6164 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6165 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6166
6167 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6168 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6169 block marker.
6170 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6171 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6175 @cindex NAND writing
6176 @cindex NAND programming
6177 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6178 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6179 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6180 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6181
6182 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6183 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6184
6185 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6186 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6187 past the end of the device.
6188 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6189 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6190 if that's being written.)
6191
6192 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6193 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6194 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6195
6196 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6197 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6198 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6199 @itemize @bullet
6200 @item no oob_* parameter
6201 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6202 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6203 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6204 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6205 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6206 @item @code{oob_only}
6207 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6208 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6209 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6210 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6211 @item @code{oob_raw}
6212 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6213 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6214 un-altered OOB.
6215 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6216 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6217 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6218 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6219 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6220 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6221 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6222 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6223 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6224 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6225 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6226 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6227 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6228 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6229 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6230 @end itemize
6231 @end deffn
6232
6233 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6234 @cindex NAND verification
6235 @cindex NAND programming
6236 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6237 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6238 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6239
6240 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6241 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6242
6243 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6244 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6245 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6246 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6247 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6248
6249 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6250 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6251 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6252
6253 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6254 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6255 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6256 be removed in a future release.
6257 @end deffn
6258
6259 @subsection Other NAND commands
6260 @cindex NAND other commands
6261
6262 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6263 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6264 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6265 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6266 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6267 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6268 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6269 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6270
6271 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6272 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6273 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6277 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6278 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6279 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6280 status for each block.
6281 @end deffn
6282
6283 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6284 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6285 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6286
6287 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6288 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6289 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6290 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6291 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6292
6293 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6294 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6295 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6296 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6297 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6298 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6299 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6300 @end deffn
6301
6302 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6303 @subsection NAND Driver List
6304 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6305 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6306 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6307
6308 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6309 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6310 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6311 address of the ECC controller.
6312 @example
6313 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6314 @end example
6315 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6316 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6317 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6318 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6319 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6320 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6321 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6322 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6323 @end deffn
6324 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6325 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6326 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6327 @end deffn
6328
6329 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6330 properly configured for input or output.
6331 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6332 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6333 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6334 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6335 @end deffn
6336 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6337 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6338 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6339 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6340 @end deffn
6341 @end deffn
6342
6343 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6344 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6345 chips from Texas Instruments.
6346 It takes three extra parameters:
6347 address of the NAND chip;
6348 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6349 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6350 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6351 @example
6352 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6353 @end example
6354 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6355 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6356 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6357 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6358 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6362 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6363 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6364 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6365 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6366 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6367 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6368 @end deffn
6369
6370 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6371 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6372 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6373 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6374 @end deffn
6375 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6376
6377 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6378 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6379 should work for this chip aswell.
6380 @end deffn
6381
6382 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6383 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6384 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6385 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6386 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6387 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6388 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6389 @example
6390 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6391 @end example
6392 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6393 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6394 without parameter query status.
6395 @end deffn
6396 @end deffn
6397
6398 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6399 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6400 parameter: the address of the controller.
6401 @example
6402 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6403 @end example
6404 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6405 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6406 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6407 change any behavior.
6408 @end deffn
6409
6410 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6411 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6412 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6413 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6414 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6415 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6416 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6417 specialized commands.
6418 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6419 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6420 change any behavior.
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @section mFlash
6424
6425 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6426 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6427
6428 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6429 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6430 address @var{base}.
6431 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6432 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6433
6434 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6435
6436 @example
6437 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6438 @end example
6439
6440 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6441
6442 @example
6443 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6444 @end example
6445 @end deffn
6446
6447 @subsection mFlash commands
6448 @cindex mFlash commands
6449
6450 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6451 Configure mflash PLL.
6452 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6453 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6454 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6455 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6459 Configure bootable option.
6460 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6461 (4kB) for boot.
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6465 Configure storage information.
6466 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6467 written.
6468 @end deffn
6469
6470 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6471 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6472 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6476 Probe mflash.
6477 @end deffn
6478
6479 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6480 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6481 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @node Flash Programming
6485 @chapter Flash Programming
6486
6487 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6488 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6489 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6490
6491 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6492 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6493
6494 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6495 @enumerate
6496 @item 'init' is executed.
6497 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6498 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6499 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6500 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6501 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6502 @end enumerate
6503
6504 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6505
6506 @example
6507 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6508 # are optional parameters
6509 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6510 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6511
6512 # binary files need the flash address passing
6513 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6514 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6515 @end example
6516
6517 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6518 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6519 @cindex PLD
6520 @cindex FPGA
6521
6522 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6523 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6524 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6525 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6526 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6527 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6528 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6529
6530 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6531
6532 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6533 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6534 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6535
6536 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6537 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6538
6539 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6540 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6541 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6542 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6543 behavior.
6544 @end deffn
6545
6546 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6547 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6548 @end deffn
6549
6550 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6551 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6552 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6553 @end deffn
6554
6555 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6556
6557 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6558 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6559 that particular type of PLD.
6560
6561 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6562 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6563 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6564
6565 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6566 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6567 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6568
6569 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6570 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6571 for FPGA @var{num}.
6572 @end deffn
6573 @end deffn
6574
6575 @node General Commands
6576 @chapter General Commands
6577 @cindex commands
6578
6579 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6580 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6581 commands are documented elsewhere.
6582
6583 Intent:
6584 @itemize @bullet
6585 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6586 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6587 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6588 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6589
6590 @item @b{From the human}
6591 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6592 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6593
6594 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6595 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6596 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6597
6598 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6599 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6600 port is 5555.
6601 @end itemize
6602
6603
6604 @section Daemon Commands
6605
6606 @deffn {Command} exit
6607 Exits the current telnet session.
6608 @end deffn
6609
6610 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6611 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6612 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6613 Not every command provides helptext.
6614
6615 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6616 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6617 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6618 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6622 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6623 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6624 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6625 Useful in connection with script files
6626 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6627 @end deffn
6628
6629 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6630 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6631 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6632 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6633 @end deffn
6634
6635 @anchor{debuglevel}
6636 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6637 @cindex message level
6638 Display debug level.
6639 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6640 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6641 Level 0 is error messages only;
6642 level 1 adds warnings;
6643 level 2 adds informational messages;
6644 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6645 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6646 the command line along with the location of that log
6647 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6648 @xref{Running}.
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6652 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6653 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6654 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6655 @example
6656 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6657 @end example
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6661 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6662 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6666 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6670 @section Target State handling
6671 @cindex reset
6672 @cindex halt
6673 @cindex target initialization
6674
6675 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6676 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6677 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6678 a current target which is used to perform the
6679 various operations. The current target may be changed
6680 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6681 target which should become current.
6682
6683 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6684 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6685 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6686 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6687 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6688
6689 @emph{With no arguments}:
6690 list all available registers for the current target,
6691 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6692 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6693 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6694 are flagged as such.
6695
6696 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6697 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6698 bypassing any internal cache.
6699
6700 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6701 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6702 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6703 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6704 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6705 relevant module will flush such values.
6706
6707 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6708 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6709
6710 @example
6711 > reg
6712 ===== ARM registers
6713 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6714 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6715 (2) r2 (/32)
6716 ...
6717 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6718 >
6719 @end example
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6723 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6724 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6725 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6726 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6727 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6728 (and enter debug mode).
6729 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6730
6731 @quotation Warning
6732 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6733 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6734 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6735 power mode by gating the core clock;
6736 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6737
6738 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6739 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6740 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6741 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6742 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6743 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6744
6745 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6746 work with a JTAG debugger.
6747 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6748 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6749 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6750 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6751 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6752 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6753 @end quotation
6754
6755 @end deffn
6756
6757 @deffn Command resume [address]
6758 Resume the target at its current code position,
6759 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6760 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6761 @end deffn
6762
6763 @deffn Command step [address]
6764 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6765 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6766 @end deffn
6767
6768 @anchor{resetcommand}
6769 @deffn Command reset
6770 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6771 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6772 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6773 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6774 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6775 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6776
6777 The optional parameter specifies what should
6778 happen after the reset.
6779 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6780 The other options will not work on all systems.
6781 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6782
6783 @itemize @minus
6784 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6785 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6786 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6787 @end itemize
6788 @end deffn
6789
6790 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6791 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6792 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6793 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6794 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6795 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6796 state.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @section I/O Utilities
6800
6801 These commands are available when
6802 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6803 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6804 notably the ZY1000.
6805 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6806
6807 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6808
6809 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6810 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6811 the text file @file{filename}.
6812 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6813 The last string is followed by a newline.
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn Command cat filename
6817 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6818 @end deffn
6819
6820 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6821 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6822 into @file{dest_filename}.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn Command ip
6826 @emph{No description provided.}
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn Command ls
6830 @emph{No description provided.}
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn Command mac
6834 @emph{No description provided.}
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn Command meminfo
6838 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6839 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn Command peek
6843 @emph{No description provided.}
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command poke
6847 @emph{No description provided.}
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn Command rm filename
6851 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6852 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6853 @end deffn
6854
6855 @deffn Command trunc filename
6856 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6860 @section Memory access commands
6861 @cindex memory access
6862
6863 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6864 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6865 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6866 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6867
6868 @enumerate
6869 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6870 to change the current target.
6871 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6872 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6873 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6874 @end enumerate
6875
6876 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6877 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6878 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6879 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6880 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6881 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6882 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6883 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6884 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6885 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6886 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6887 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6888 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6889 @end deffn
6890
6891 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6892 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6893 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6894 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6895 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6896 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6897 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6898 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6899 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6900 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @anchor{imageaccess}
6904 @section Image loading commands
6905 @cindex image loading
6906 @cindex image dumping
6907
6908 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6909 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6910 binary file named @var{filename}.
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6914 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6915 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6919 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6920 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6921 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6922 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6923 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6924 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6925 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6926 separately.
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6930 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6931 The file format may optionally be specified
6932 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6933 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6934 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6935 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6936 @example
6937 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6938 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6939 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6940 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6941 $address $length
6942 @}
6943 @end example
6944 @end deffn
6945
6946 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6947 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6948 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6949 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6950 The file format may optionally be specified
6951 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6952 @end deffn
6953
6954 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6955 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6956 The file format may optionally be specified
6957 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6958 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961
6962 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6963 @cindex breakpoint
6964 @cindex watchpoint
6965
6966 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6967 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6968 watchpoints.
6969 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6970
6971 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6972 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6973 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6974 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6975 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6976 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6977
6978 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6979 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6980 @end deffn
6981
6982 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6983 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6984 @end deffn
6985
6986 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6987 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6991 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6992 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6993 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6994 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6995 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6996 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6997 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6998 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @section Misc Commands
7002
7003 @cindex profiling
7004 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7005 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7006 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7007 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7008 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7009 limit the address range.
7010 @end deffn
7011
7012 @deffn Command {version}
7013 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7017 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7018 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7022 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7023 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7024 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7025
7026 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7027 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7028 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7029 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7030
7031 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7032 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7033 @cindex tracing
7034 @cindex ETM
7035 @cindex ETB
7036
7037 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7038 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7039 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7040
7041 @itemize
7042 @item
7043 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7044 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7045 supports such an interface.
7046 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7047 and trace port support.)
7048 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7049 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7050 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7051 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7052 in the board-specific configuration file.
7053 @item
7054 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7055 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7056 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7057 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7058 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7059 @end itemize
7060
7061 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7062
7063 @quotation Issues
7064 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7065 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7066
7067 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7068 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7069 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7070 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7071 dummy trace port driver}.
7072
7073 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7074 as well as tracing only during specific states
7075 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7076
7077 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7078 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7079 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7080 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7081 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7082
7083 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7084 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7085 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7086 this original style of JTAG access.
7087 @end quotation
7088
7089 @subsection ETM Configuration
7090 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7091
7092 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7093 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7094 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7095
7096 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7097 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7098 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7099 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7100 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7101 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7102 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7103 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7104 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7105
7106 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7107 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7108 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7109
7110 @quotation Warning
7111 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7112 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7113 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7114 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7115 @end quotation
7116
7117 @quotation Note
7118 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7119 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7120 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7121 what CPU activities are traced.
7122 @end quotation
7123 @end deffn
7124
7125 @deffn Command {etm info}
7126 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7127 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7128 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7129 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn Command {etm status}
7133 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7134 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7135 Did trace data overflow?
7136 Was it triggered?
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7140 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7141 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7142 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7143 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7144
7145 @itemize
7146 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7147 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7148 The value is one of
7149 @option{none} (save nothing),
7150 @option{data} (save data),
7151 @option{address} (save addresses),
7152 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7153 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7154 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7155 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7156 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7157 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7158 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7159 trace stream without an image of the code.
7160 @end itemize
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7164 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7165 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7166 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7167 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7168
7169 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7170 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7171 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7175
7176 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7177 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7178 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7179
7180 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7181 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7182 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7183 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7184 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7185 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7186 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7187
7188 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7189
7190 @itemize
7191 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7192 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7193 for instruction access within that function's body.
7194 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7195 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7196 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7197 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7198 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7199 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7200 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7201 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7202 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7203 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7204 @item @emph{... more}
7205 @end itemize
7206
7207 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7208 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7209
7210 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7211 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7212 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7216 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7217 @end deffn
7218
7219 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7220 Opens an image file.
7221 @end deffn
7222
7223 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7224 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7225 @end deffn
7226
7227 @deffn Command {etm start}
7228 Starts trace data collection.
7229 @end deffn
7230
7231 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7232 Stops trace data collection.
7233 @end deffn
7234
7235 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7236 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7237
7238 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7239
7240 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7241 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7242 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7243 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7244 any trace data collection.}
7245 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7246 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7247 @end deffn
7248 @end deffn
7249
7250 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7251 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7252 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7253 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7254 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7255 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7256 @end deffn
7257 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7258 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7259 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7260 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7261 trace trigger becomes active.
7262
7263 @itemize
7264 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7265 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7266 afterwards.
7267 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7268 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7269 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7270 what caused that event to happen.
7271 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7272 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7273 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7274 how the event caused trouble.
7275 @end itemize
7276 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7277 @end deffn
7278
7279 @end deffn
7280
7281 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7282 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7283 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7284 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7285 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7286
7287 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7288 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7289
7290 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7291 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7292 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7293 @end deffn
7294
7295 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7296 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7297 @end deffn
7298
7299 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7300 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7301 @end deffn
7302 @end deffn
7303
7304
7305 @section Generic ARM
7306 @cindex ARM
7307
7308 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7309 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7310 commands that may be available.
7311
7312 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7313 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7314 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7315 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7316 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7317 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7318 @end deffn
7319
7320 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7321 @cindex disassemble
7322 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7323 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7324 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7325 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7326 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7327 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7328 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7329
7330 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7331 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7332 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7333 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7334 with a handful of exceptions.
7335 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7339 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7340 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7341 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7342 and using the MCR instruction.
7343 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7344 an ARM register.)
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7348 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7349 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7350 and the MRC instruction.
7351 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7352 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7353 an ARM register.)
7354 @end deffn
7355
7356 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7357 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7358 core mode if necessary.
7359 @end deffn
7360
7361 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7362 @cindex ARM semihosting
7363 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7364
7365 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7366 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7367 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7368 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7369 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7370 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7371 @end deffn
7372
7373 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7374 @cindex ARMv4
7375 @cindex ARMv5
7376
7377 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7378 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7379 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7380 variant.
7381
7382 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7383 @cindex ARM7
7384 @cindex ARM9
7385
7386 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7387 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7388 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7389 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7390
7391 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7392 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7393 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7394 instead of breakpoints.
7395 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7396
7397 This should be
7398 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7399 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7400 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7401 @end deffn
7402
7403 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7404 @cindex DCC
7405 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7406 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7407 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7408
7409 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7410 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7411 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7415 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7416 that don't check completion of the operation.
7417 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7418
7419 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7420 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7421 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7422 @end deffn
7423
7424 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7425 @cindex ARM720T
7426
7427 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7428 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7429 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7430 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7431
7432 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7433 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7434 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7435
7436 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7437 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7438 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7442 @cindex ARM9
7443
7444 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7445 integer processors.
7446 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7447
7448 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7449 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7450 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7451 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7452
7453 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7454 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7455 @cindex vector_catch
7456 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7457 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7458 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7459 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7460 to those hardware vectors.
7461
7462 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7463 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7464 vector catch hardware to intercept
7465 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7466 @option{none} of them,
7467 or a list with one or more of the following:
7468 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7469 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7473 @cindex ARM920T
7474
7475 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7476 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7477 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7478 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7479 and ARM9 commands.
7480
7481 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7482 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7483 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7487 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7488 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7489 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7490 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7491 (Not all registers can be written.)
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7495 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7496 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7497
7498 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7499 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7500 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7501 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7502 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7503 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7504 @end deffn
7505
7506 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7507 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7508 @end deffn
7509
7510 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7511 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7512 @end deffn
7513
7514 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7515 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7516
7517 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7518 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7519 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7520 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7521 and ARM9 commands.
7522
7523 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7524 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7525
7526 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7527 Print information about the caches found.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7531 @cindex ARM966E
7532
7533 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7534 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7535 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7536 and ARM9 commands.
7537
7538 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7539 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7540 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7541 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7542 ARM966E-S TRM.
7543 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7544 as required for BIST support.
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @subsection XScale specific commands
7548 @cindex XScale
7549
7550 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7551
7552 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7553 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7554 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7555 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7556 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7557 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7558 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7559
7560 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7561 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7562 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7563 the mini-IC.
7564
7565 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7566 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7567 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7568 code layout in memory:
7569 @example
7570 _vectors:
7571 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7572 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7573 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7574 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7575 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7576 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7577 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7578 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7579 .org 0x100
7580 .long real_reset_vector
7581 .long real_ui_handler
7582 .long real_swi_handler
7583 .long real_pf_abort
7584 .long real_data_abort
7585 .long 0 /* unused */
7586 .long real_irq_handler
7587 .long real_fiq_handler
7588 @end example
7589
7590 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7591 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7592 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7593 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7594 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7595 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7596 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7597 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7598 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7599 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7600 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7601 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7602 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7603 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7604 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7605 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7606 software.
7607
7608 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7609 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7610 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7611 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7612
7613 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7614 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7615 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7616 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7617 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7618 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7619 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7620 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7621 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7622
7623 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7624 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7625
7626 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7627 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7628 @end deffn
7629
7630 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7631 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7632 @end deffn
7633
7634 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7635 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7636 @end deffn
7637
7638 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7639 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7640 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7644 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7645 @end deffn
7646
7647 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7648 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7652 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7653 @end deffn
7654
7655 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7656 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7657 @end deffn
7658
7659 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7660 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7664 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7665 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7666 and modifying how it is emptied.
7667 @end deffn
7668
7669 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7670 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7671 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7672 The image @var{type} may be one of
7673 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7674 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7675 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7679 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7680 @cindex vector_catch
7681 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7682 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7683
7684 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7685 @example
7686 0x01 Trap Reset
7687 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7688 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7689 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7690 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7691 0x20 reserved
7692 0x40 Trap IRQ
7693 0x80 Trap FIQ
7694 @end example
7695 @end deffn
7696
7697 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7698 @cindex vector_table
7699
7700 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7701 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7702 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7703 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7704 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7705
7706 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7707
7708 @end deffn
7709
7710 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7711 @cindex ARMv6
7712
7713 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7714 @cindex ARM11
7715
7716 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7717 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7718 which is enabled by default.
7719 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7720 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7721 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7722 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7723 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7724 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7725 @end deffn
7726
7727 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7728 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7729 which is enabled by default.
7730 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7731 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7735 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7736 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7737 they are disabled by default.
7738 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7739 @end deffn
7740
7741 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7742 @cindex vector_catch
7743 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7744 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7745 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7746
7747 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7748 for certain hardware events.
7749 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7750 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7751 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7752 @end deffn
7753
7754 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7755 @cindex ARMv7
7756
7757 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7758 @cindex Debug Access Port
7759 @cindex DAP
7760 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7761 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7762 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7763
7764 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7765 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7766 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7770 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7771 @end deffn
7772
7773 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7774 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7775 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7776 @end deffn
7777
7778 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7779 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7780 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7781 @end deffn
7782
7783 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7784 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7785 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7786 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7787 @end deffn
7788
7789 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7790 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7791 Defaulting to 0.
7792 @end deffn
7793
7794 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7795 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7796 Disabled by default
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799
7800 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7801 @cindex Cortex-A
7802
7803 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7804 display information about target caches
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7808 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7809 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7810 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7811 Defaults to 'off'.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7815 Initialize core debug
7816 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7817 @end deffn
7818
7819 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7820 Disable SMP mode
7821 @end deffn
7822
7823 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7824 Enable SMP mode
7825 @end deffn
7826
7827 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7828 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7829 @end deffn
7830
7831 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7832 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7833 @end deffn
7834
7835 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7836 configure l2x cache
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839
7840 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7841 @cindex Cortex-R
7842
7843 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7844 Initialize core debug
7845 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7846 @end deffn
7847
7848 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7849 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7850 @end deffn
7851
7852
7853 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7854 @cindex tracing
7855 @cindex SWO
7856 @cindex SWV
7857 @cindex TPIU
7858 @cindex ITM
7859 @cindex ETM
7860
7861 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7862 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7863 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7864
7865 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7866 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7867 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7868 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7869
7870 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7871 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7872 debugger adapter features.
7873
7874 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7875 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7876
7877 Command options:
7878 @itemize @minus
7879 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7880 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7881 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7882 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7883 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7884 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7885 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7886 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7887 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7888 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7889 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7890 coding;
7891 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7892 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7893 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7894 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7895 data is to be output via SWO;
7896 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7897 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7898 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7899 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7900 rate automatically.
7901 @end itemize
7902
7903 Example usage:
7904 @enumerate
7905 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7906 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7907 enough to:
7908 @example
7909 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7910 ...
7911 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7912 ...
7913 @end example
7914 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7915 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7916 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7917 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7918 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7919 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7920 @example
7921 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7922 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7923 @end example
7924 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7925 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7926 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7927 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7928 @example
7929 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7930 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7931 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7932 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7933 @end example
7934 @end enumerate
7935 @end deffn
7936
7937 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7938 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7939 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7940 @end deffn
7941
7942 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7943 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7944 @end deffn
7945
7946 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7947 @cindex Cortex-M
7948
7949 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7950 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7951
7952 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7953 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7954 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7955 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7956 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7957 the step command leaves with the core running.
7958
7959 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7960 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7961 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7962
7963 Default is @option{auto}.
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7967 @cindex vector_catch
7968 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7969 for certain hardware events.
7970
7971 Parameters request interception of
7972 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7973 @option{none} of them,
7974 or one or more of the following:
7975 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7976 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7977 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7978 @option{irq_err},
7979 @option{state_err},
7980 @option{chk_err}, or
7981 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7982 @option{reset}.
7983 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7984 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7985 are mapped to HardFault.
7986 UsageFault checks for
7987 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7988 must also be explicitly enabled.
7989
7990 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7991 @end deffn
7992
7993 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7994 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7995 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7996 @itemize @minus
7997 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7998 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7999 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8000 @end itemize
8001 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8002 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8003 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8004 the peripherals.
8005 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8006 @end deffn
8007
8008 @section Intel Architecture
8009
8010 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8011 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8012 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8013 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8014 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8015 @itemize
8016 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8017 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8018 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8019 @end itemize
8020
8021 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8022 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8023 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8024
8025 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8026 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8027 @end deffn
8028
8029 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8030 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8034 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8038 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8039 @end deffn
8040
8041 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8042 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8043 @end deffn
8044
8045 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8046 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8047 @end deffn
8048
8049 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8050
8051 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8052 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8053
8054 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8055 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8056 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8057 @end deffn
8058 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8059 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8060
8061 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8062
8063 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8064 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8065 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8066 @end deffn
8067
8068 @subsection Registers commands
8069 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8070 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8071 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8072
8073 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8074
8075 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8076 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8077 and "timer" groups.
8078
8079 @emph{example:}
8080 @example
8081 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8082 @end example
8083
8084
8085 @end deffn
8086 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8087 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8088
8089 @emph{group} can be "system",
8090 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8091 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8095 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8096 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8097 @cindex tracing
8098 @cindex libdcc
8099 @cindex DCC
8100 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8101 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8102 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8103 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8104
8105 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8106 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8107 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8108 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8109 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8110 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8111
8112 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8113 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8114 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8115 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8116 The target being debugged may
8117 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8118 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8119 each supported by a command:
8120
8121 @itemize
8122 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8123 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8124 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8125 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8126
8127 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8128 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8129 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8130
8131 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8132 and then displayed at any time.
8133 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8134
8135 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8136 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8137 @end itemize
8138
8139 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8140 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8141 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8142 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8143 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8144 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8145 does the same thing.
8146
8147 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8148 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8149 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8150 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8151 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8152
8153 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8154 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8155 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8156 @end deffn
8157
8158 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8159 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8160 in the order they triggered.
8161 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8162 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8163 history records.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8167 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8168 they have been triggered.
8169 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8170 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8171 and associates it with that identifier.
8172
8173 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8174 are not related except by this command.
8175 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8176 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8177 @end deffn
8178
8179
8180 @node JTAG Commands
8181 @chapter JTAG Commands
8182 @cindex JTAG Commands
8183 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8184 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8185 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8186 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8187 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8188
8189 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8190 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8191
8192 @itemize @bullet
8193 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8194 devices such as a CPUs.
8195 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8196 standard state machine (in parallel)
8197 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8198 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8199 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8200 while the reading previous ones.
8201 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8202 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8203 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8204 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8205 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8206 registers.
8207 @end itemize
8208
8209 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8210
8211 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8212 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8213 the order of TAP state transitions.
8214 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8215 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8216 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8217 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8218 these commands are not available.
8219
8220 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8221 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8222 that specify the entire register.
8223 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8224 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8225 The return value holds the original value of each
8226 of those fields.
8227
8228 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8229 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8230 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8231 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8232 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8233
8234 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8235 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8236
8237 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8238 in that state.
8239 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8240 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8241 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8242
8243 @quotation Warning
8244 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8245 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8246 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8247 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8248 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8249 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8250 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8251 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8252 @end quotation
8253 @end deffn
8254
8255 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8256 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8257 This may be used for performance tuning.
8258
8259 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8260 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8261 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8262 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8263 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8264 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8265 @end deffn
8266
8267 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8268 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8269 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8270 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8271 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8272 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8273
8274 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8275 in that state.
8276 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8277 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8278 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8279
8280 @quotation Note
8281 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8282 register values, unlike data register values.
8283 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8284 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8285 @end quotation
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8289 Set values of reset signals.
8290 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8291 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8292 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8293 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8294 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8295 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8296 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8297
8298 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8299 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8300 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8301 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8302 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8303 instead of the TRST signal.
8304 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8305 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8306 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8307 with handlers for that event.
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8311 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8312 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8313 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8314 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8315 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8316 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8317 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8318 The final state must also be stable.
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8322 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8323 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8324 Instructions often need some time
8325 to execute before they take effect.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8329 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8330
8331 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8332 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8333 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8334 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8335 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8336 @end deffn
8337
8338 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8339 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8340 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8341 must also be enabled.
8342 Default is enabled.
8343 @end deffn
8344
8345 @section TAP state names
8346 @cindex TAP state names
8347
8348 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8349 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8350 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8351 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8352
8353 @itemize @bullet
8354 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8355 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8356 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8357 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8358 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8359 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8360 through the data register
8361 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8362 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8363 for update or more shifting
8364 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8365 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8366 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8367 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8368 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8369 through the instruction register
8370 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8371 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8372 for update or more shifting
8373 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8374 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8375 @end itemize
8376
8377 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8378 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8379 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8380 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8381
8382 @itemize @bullet
8383 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8384 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8385 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8386 may not be as expected.
8387 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8388 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8389 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8390 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8391 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8392 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8393 @end itemize
8394
8395 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8396 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8397
8398 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8399 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8400 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8401 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8402
8403 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8404 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8405 @cindex SVF
8406
8407 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8408 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8409 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8410 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8411
8412 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8413 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8414 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8415 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8416 each command is logged before it is executed.
8417 @end deffn
8418
8419 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8420 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8421 @cindex XSVF
8422
8423 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8424 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8425 Xilinx devices.
8426 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8427 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8428
8429 @quotation Important
8430 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8431 @end quotation
8432
8433 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8434 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8435 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8436 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8437 that TAP.
8438 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8439 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8440 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8441 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8442 @end deffn
8443
8444 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8445 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8446 after building the software.
8447 You may find them useful:
8448
8449 @itemize
8450 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8451 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8452 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8453 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8454 @end itemize
8455
8456 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8457 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8458 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8459 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8460 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8461 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8462 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8463
8464
8465 @node Utility Commands
8466 @chapter Utility Commands
8467 @cindex Utility Commands
8468
8469 @section RAM testing
8470 @cindex RAM testing
8471
8472 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8473 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8474 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8475 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8476 hardware problems.
8477
8478 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8479 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8480 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8481 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8482
8483 Load the memory testing functions with
8484
8485 @example
8486 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8487 @end example
8488
8489 to get access to the following facilities:
8490
8491 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8492 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8493 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8494 @end deffn
8495
8496 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8497 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8498 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8499 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8500 @end deffn
8501
8502 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8503 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8504 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8505 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8506 @end deffn
8507
8508 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8509 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8510 @end deffn
8511
8512 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8513 @cindex Firmware recovery
8514
8515 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8516 devices recovery with JTAG.
8517
8518 For quickstart instructions run:
8519 @example
8520 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8521 @end example
8522
8523 @node TFTP
8524 @chapter TFTP
8525 @cindex TFTP
8526 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8527 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8528
8529 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8530 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8531 server (tftpd). For example,
8532
8533 @example
8534 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8535 @end example
8536
8537 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8538 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8539
8540 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8541 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8542 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8543 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8544
8545 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8546 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8547 @cindex GDB
8548 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8549 to debug remote targets.
8550 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8551
8552 @itemize
8553 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8554 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8555 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8556 as shown in this chapter.
8557 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8558 that also will probably need to be configured.
8559 @end itemize
8560
8561 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8562 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8563 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8564 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8565 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8566 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8567
8568 @section Connecting to GDB
8569 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8570 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8571 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8572 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8573 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8574
8575 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8576
8577 @enumerate
8578 @item
8579 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8580 @example
8581 target remote localhost:3333
8582 @end example
8583 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8584
8585 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8586 @example
8587 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8588 @end example
8589 @item
8590 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8591 @example
8592 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8593 @end example
8594 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8595 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8596 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8597 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8598 @end enumerate
8599
8600 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8601 GDB command line.
8602
8603 @section Sample GDB session startup
8604
8605 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8606 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8607 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8608 small ARM program.
8609 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8610 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8611
8612 @example
8613 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8614 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8615 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8616 ...
8617 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8618 ...
8619 (gdb) load
8620 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8621 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8622 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8623 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8624 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8625 (gdb) continue
8626 Continuing.
8627 ...
8628 @end example
8629
8630 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8631 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8632 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8633 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8634
8635 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8636
8637 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8638 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8639 packet size and the device's memory map.
8640 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8641 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8642 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8643
8644 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8645 You may need to set those up by hand.
8646 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8647 something like:
8648
8649 @example
8650 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8651 @end example
8652
8653 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8654
8655 @example
8656 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8657 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8658 @end example
8659
8660 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8661 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8662 do not have such restrictions.
8663
8664 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8665 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8666 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8667
8668 @example
8669 define hook-step
8670 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8671 end
8672 define hookpost-step
8673 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8674 end
8675 @end example
8676
8677 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8678 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8679 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8680 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8681
8682 @section Programming using GDB
8683 @cindex Programming using GDB
8684 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8685
8686 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8687 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8688 @example
8689 gdb_memory_map disable
8690 @end example
8691 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8692 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8693 working area.
8694
8695 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8696 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8697 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8698 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8699
8700 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8701 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8702
8703 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8704 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8705 @example
8706 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8707 @end example
8708
8709 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8710 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8711
8712 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8713 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8714 will be used.
8715
8716 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8717 script can be executed:
8718 @example
8719 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8720 @end example
8721
8722 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8723 can be used.
8724 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8725 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8726 @cindex SMP
8727 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8728 @itemize @bullet
8729 @item j - smp status request
8730 @item J - smp set request
8731 @end itemize
8732
8733 OpenOCD implements :
8734 @itemize @bullet
8735 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8736 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8737 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8738 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8739 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8740 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8741 @end itemize
8742
8743 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8744 @itemize @bullet
8745 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8746 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8747 @example
8748 set $_core 1
8749 #Jc01 packet is sent
8750 print $_core
8751 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8752 @end example
8753
8754 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8755 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8756
8757 @example
8758 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8759 define toggle0
8760 maint packet Jc0
8761 continue
8762 main packet Jc-1
8763 end
8764 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8765 define toggle1
8766 maint packet Jc1
8767 continue
8768 main packet Jc-1
8769 end
8770 @end example
8771 @end itemize
8772
8773 @section RTOS Support
8774 @cindex RTOS Support
8775 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8776
8777 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8778 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8779
8780 @* An example setup is below:
8781
8782 @example
8783 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8784 @end example
8785
8786 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8787
8788 Currently supported rtos's include:
8789 @itemize @bullet
8790 @item @option{eCos}
8791 @item @option{ThreadX}
8792 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8793 @item @option{linux}
8794 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8795 @item @option{embKernel}
8796 @item @option{mqx}
8797 @end itemize
8798
8799 @quotation Note
8800 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8801 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8802 @end quotation
8803
8804 @table @code
8805 @item eCos symbols
8806 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8807 @item ThreadX symbols
8808 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8809 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8810 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8811 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8812 @tex
8813 \begingroup
8814 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8815 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8816 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8817 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8818 \par
8819 \endgroup
8820 @end tex
8821 @item linux symbols
8822 init_task.
8823 @item ChibiOS symbols
8824 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8825 @item embKernel symbols
8826 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8827 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8828 @item mqx symbols
8829 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8830 @end table
8831
8832 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8833 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8834
8835 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8836 along with the project:
8837
8838 @table @code
8839 @item FreeRTOS
8840 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8841 @end table
8842
8843 @node Tcl Scripting API
8844 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8845 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8846 @cindex Tcl scripts
8847 @section API rules
8848
8849 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8850 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8851 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8852
8853 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8854 pair list and lists.
8855
8856 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8857 list.
8858
8859 @example
8860 > set foo(me) Duane
8861 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8862 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8863 > set foo(duck) Donald
8864 @end example
8865
8866 If one does this:
8867
8868 @example
8869 > set foo
8870 @end example
8871
8872 The result is:
8873
8874 @example
8875 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8876 @end example
8877
8878 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8879
8880 @verbatim
8881 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8882 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8883 }
8884 @end verbatim
8885
8886 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8887 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8888
8889 @section Internal low-level Commands
8890
8891 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8892 invoke directly.
8893
8894 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8895 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8896 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8897
8898 @itemize @bullet
8899 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8900
8901 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8902 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8903
8904 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8905 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8906
8907 Return information about the flash banks
8908
8909 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8910
8911 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8912 its execution. Example:
8913
8914 @example
8915 > capture "reset init"
8916 @end example
8917
8918 @end itemize
8919
8920 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8921 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8922 called "flash_banks".
8923
8924 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8925
8926 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8927 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8928 holds one of the following values:
8929
8930 @itemize @bullet
8931 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8932 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8933 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8934 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8935 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8936 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8937 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8938 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8939 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8940 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8941 @end itemize
8942
8943 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8944
8945 @quotation Note
8946 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8947 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8948 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8949 is jim, not real tcl).
8950 @end quotation
8951
8952 @section Tcl RPC server
8953 @cindex RPC
8954
8955 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8956 commands and receive the results.
8957
8958 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8959 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8960 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8961 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8962 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8963
8964 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8965 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8966 @command{capture} command.
8967
8968 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8969
8970 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8971 @cindex RPC Notifications
8972
8973 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8974 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8975
8976 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8977 in the following format.
8978
8979 @verbatim
8980 type target_event event [event-name]
8981 type target_state state [state-name]
8982 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8983 @end verbatim
8984
8985 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8986 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8987 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8988 Defaults to off.
8989
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
8993 @cindex RPC trace output
8994
8995 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8996 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8997
8998 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
8999
9000 @verbatim
9001 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9002 @end verbatim
9003
9004 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9005 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9006 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9007 Defaults to off.
9008
9009 See an example application here:
9010 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9011
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @node FAQ
9015 @chapter FAQ
9016 @cindex faq
9017 @enumerate
9018 @anchor{faqrtck}
9019 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9020 @cindex RTCK
9021 @cindex adaptive clocking
9022 @*
9023
9024 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9025 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9026 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9027 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9028
9029 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9030 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9031 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9032 @enumerate
9033 @item
9034 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9035 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9036 @item
9037 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9038 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9039 @end enumerate
9040
9041 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9042 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9043 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9044 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9045 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9046 power).
9047
9048 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9049 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9050 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9051 ARM926 scenario).
9052 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9053 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9054 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9055
9056 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9057 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9058 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9059 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9060
9061 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9062
9063 In order to make use of this,
9064 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9065 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9066
9067 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9068 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9069 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9070 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9071 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9072
9073 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9074 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9075 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9076 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9077
9078 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9079 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9080 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9081 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9082 with a CPLD.
9083 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9084 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9085 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9086 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9087 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9088 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9089
9090 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9091
9092 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9093
9094 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9095 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9096 depending on the chips on your board.
9097 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9098 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9099 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9100
9101 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9102 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9103 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9104
9105 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9106 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9107 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9108 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9109
9110 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9111 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9112 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9113 this way.
9114
9115 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9116 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9117 clock rate.
9118 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9119 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9120 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9121
9122 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9123
9124 @example
9125 # Example: 1.234MHz
9126 adapter_khz 1234
9127 @end example
9128
9129
9130 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9131
9132 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9133 around Windows filenames.
9134
9135 @example
9136 > echo \a
9137
9138 > echo @{\a@}
9139 \a
9140 > echo "\a"
9141
9142 >
9143 @end example
9144
9145
9146 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9147
9148 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9149 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9150 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9151
9152 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9153 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9154 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9155
9156 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9157 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9158 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9159
9160 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9161
9162 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9163 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9164 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9165 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9166
9167 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9168 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9169 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9170
9171 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9172 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9173
9174 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9175 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9176 memory read caused data abort".
9177
9178 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9179 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9180 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9181 be done, feel free to add this here.
9182
9183 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9184 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9185 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9186 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9187 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9188 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9189 gracefully stops.
9190
9191 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9192 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9193 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9194
9195 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9196 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9197 bytes. Painful...
9198
9199
9200 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9201 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9202
9203 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9204 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9205 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9206 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9207 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9208 reset, everything else should work fine.
9209
9210 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9211 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9212 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9213 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9214
9215 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9216 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9217 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9218 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9219
9220 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9221
9222 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
9223 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
9224 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
9225 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9226
9227 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
9228 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
9229 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
9230 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
9231
9232 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9233 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9234 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9235
9236 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9237 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9238
9239 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9240 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9241 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9242 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9243 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9244 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9245 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9246 clock frequency?
9247
9248 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9249 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9250 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9251 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9252 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9253
9254 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9255
9256 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9257 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9258 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9259 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9260 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9261 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9262 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9263
9264 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9265
9266 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9267 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9268 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9269 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9270
9271 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9272 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9273 particular order?
9274
9275 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9276 the same order used by the hardware.
9277
9278 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9279 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9280 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9281 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9282 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9283 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9284
9285 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9286 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9287 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9288 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9289
9290 @itemize @bullet
9291 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9292 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9293 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9294 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9295 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9296 @end itemize
9297
9298 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9299
9300 @itemize @bullet
9301 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9302 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9303 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9304 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9305 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9306 @end itemize
9307
9308
9309 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9310 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9311 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9312
9313 TODO.
9314
9315 @end enumerate
9316
9317 @node Tcl Crash Course
9318 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9319 @cindex Tcl
9320
9321 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9322 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9323 how the Tcl scripts work.
9324
9325 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9326 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9327 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9328 OpenOCD.
9329
9330 @section Tcl Rule #1
9331 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9332 @enumerate
9333 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9334 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9335 @end enumerate
9336
9337 The Tcl equal is this:
9338
9339 @enumerate
9340 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9341 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9342 @end enumerate
9343
9344 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9345 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9346
9347 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9348 There is a second pair of rules.
9349 @enumerate
9350 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9351 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9352 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9353 in Tcl.
9354 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9355 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9356 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9357 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9358 @end enumerate
9359
9360 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9361 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9362 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9363 Everything is a string}
9364
9365 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9366 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9367 difference is subtle.
9368 @enumerate
9369 @item Parse Time
9370 @item Evaluation Time
9371 @end enumerate
9372
9373 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9374 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9375 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9376
9377 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9378 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9379 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9380 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9381
9382 @itemize @bullet
9383 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9384 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9385 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9386 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9387 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9388 @example
9389 # bash example
9390 X=`date`
9391 echo "The Date is: $X"
9392 # Tcl example
9393 set X [date]
9394 puts "The Date is: $X"
9395 @end example
9396 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9397 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9398 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9399 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9400 is a string}
9401 @example
9402 set x "Dinner"
9403 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9404 @end example
9405 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9406 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9407 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9408 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9409 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9410 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9411 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9412 @end itemize
9413
9414 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9415
9416 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9417
9418 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9419
9420 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9421 the normal way.
9422
9423 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9424 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9425 line is immedatly executed.
9426
9427 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9428 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9429
9430 @subsection Command Execution
9431
9432 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9433 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9434 control flow operators.
9435
9436 Commands are executed like this:
9437
9438 @enumerate
9439 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9440 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9441 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9442 @end enumerate
9443
9444 It sort of works like this:
9445 @example
9446 for(;;)@{
9447 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9448
9449 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9450
9451 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9452 @}
9453 @end example
9454
9455 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9456 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9457 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9458 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9459 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9460 ``LookupCommand()''
9461
9462 @subsection The FOR command
9463
9464 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9465 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9466 command just like any other command.
9467
9468 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9469 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9470 are:
9471
9472 @enumerate 0
9473 @item The ascii text 'for'
9474 @item The start text
9475 @item The test expression
9476 @item The next text
9477 @item The body text
9478 @end enumerate
9479
9480 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9481 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9482 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9483 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9484
9485 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9486 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9487
9488 @example
9489 int
9490 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9491 int *argc,
9492 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9493 @end example
9494
9495 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9496 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9497 still operates in the same basic way.
9498
9499 @subsection FOR command implementation
9500
9501 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9502 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9503
9504 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9505
9506 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9507
9508 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9509 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9510 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9511
9512 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9513 expression and returns a value.
9514
9515 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9516 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9517 @example
9518 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9519
9520 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9521
9522 int
9523 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9524 int argc,
9525 char **argv )
9526 @{
9527 if( argc != 5 )@{
9528 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9529 return ERROR;
9530 @}
9531
9532 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9533
9534 // Execute the start statement.
9535 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9536
9537 // Top of loop test
9538 for(;;)@{
9539 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9540 if( i == 0 )
9541 break;
9542
9543 // Execute the body
9544 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9545
9546 // Execute the LOOP part
9547 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9548 @}
9549
9550 // Return no error
9551 SetResult( interp, "" );
9552 return SUCCESS;
9553 @}
9554 @end example
9555
9556 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9557 in the same basic way.
9558
9559 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9560
9561 @subsection source and find commands
9562 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9563 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9564 @*Remember the parsing rules
9565 @enumerate
9566 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9567 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9568 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9569 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9570 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9571 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9572 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9573 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9574 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9575 @end enumerate
9576 @subsection format command
9577 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9578 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9579 @b{sprintf()}.
9580 @b{Example}
9581 @example
9582 set x 6
9583 set y 7
9584 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9585 @end example
9586 @enumerate
9587 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9588 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9589 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9590 @* Refer to Rule #1
9591 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9592 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9593 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9594 @end enumerate
9595 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9596 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9597 @example
9598 #1 Good
9599 proc someproc @{@} @{
9600 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9601 @}
9602 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9603 #2 Good - no variables
9604 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9605 #3 Good Curly Braces
9606 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9607 puts "Time: [date]"
9608 @}
9609 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9610 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9611 @end example
9612 @enumerate
9613 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9614 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9615 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9616 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9617 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9618 command.
9619 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9620 @*There are 4 examples:
9621 @enumerate
9622 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9623 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9624 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9625 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9626 @end enumerate
9627
9628 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9629 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9630 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9631
9632 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9633 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9634 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9635 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9636 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9637 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9638 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9639 @end enumerate
9640 @subsection Global Variables
9641 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9642 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9643 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9644 @example
9645 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9646 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9647 global x #Global variable X
9648 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9649 @}
9650 @end example
9651 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9652 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9653 @example
9654 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9655 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9656 # Create var name
9657 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9658 # Make it a global
9659 global $vn
9660 # Set it.
9661 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9662 @}
9663 @end example
9664 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9665 @example
9666 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9667 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9668 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9669 @}
9670 @end example
9671
9672 @include fdl.texi
9673
9674 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9675 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9676 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9677 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9678 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9679 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9680
9681 @printindex cp
9682
9683 @node Command and Driver Index
9684 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9685 @printindex fn
9686
9687 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)